blob: fdc4828cf11a0cbedb033c997d84f5b36d1f59c9 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000041
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +000059 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
60 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
61 // emit them now.
62 llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >::iterator
63 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
64 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
65 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
66 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
67 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
68
69 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
70 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't remove this
71 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
72 // diagnostics again.
73 Suppressed.clear();
74 }
75 }
76
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000077 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerbfac7dc2010-10-09 15:49:00 +000078 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
79 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000080
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000081 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc74073c2010-10-06 23:12:32 +000082 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
83 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
84 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
85 else
86 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerbfac7dc2010-10-09 15:49:00 +000087 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000088 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
89 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000090
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000091 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000092 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000093 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
94 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
95 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
96 return true;
97 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000098 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000099
Anders Carlsson73067a02010-10-22 23:37:08 +0000100 // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
101 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
102 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
103
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000104 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +0000105}
106
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000107/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000108/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000109/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
110///
111void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000112 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +0000113 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000114 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000115 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000116
117 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
118 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000119 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
120 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000121
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000122 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
123 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000124 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000125 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
126 int isMethod = 0;
127 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
128 // skip over named parameters.
129 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
130 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
131 if (nullPos)
132 --nullPos;
133 else
134 ++i;
135 }
136 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
137 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000138 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000139 // skip over named parameters.
140 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
141 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
142 if (nullPos)
143 --nullPos;
144 else
145 ++i;
146 }
147 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000148 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000149 // block or function pointer call.
150 QualType Ty = V->getType();
151 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000152 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000153 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
154 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000155 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
156 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
157 unsigned k;
158 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
159 if (nullPos)
160 --nullPos;
161 else
162 ++i;
163 }
164 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
165 }
166 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
167 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000168 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000169 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000170 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000171 return;
172
173 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000174 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000175 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000176 return;
177 }
178 int sentinel = i;
179 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
180 --sentinelPos;
181 ++i;
182 }
183 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
184 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000185 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000186 return;
187 }
188 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
189 ++i;
190 ++sentinel;
191 }
192 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000193 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
194 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
195 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000196 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000197 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
198 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
199 return;
200
201 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
202 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
203
204 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
205 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000206}
207
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000208SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
209 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
210 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
211}
212
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
214// Standard Promotions and Conversions
215//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
216
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000217/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
218void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
219 QualType Ty = E->getType();
220 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
221
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000222 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000223 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000224 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000225 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
226 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
227 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
228 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
229 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
230 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
231 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000232 //
233 // C++ 4.2p1:
234 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
235 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
236 //
237 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
238 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000239 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000240 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000241 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000242}
243
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000244void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
245 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000246
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000247 QualType Ty = E->getType();
248 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
249 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
250 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
251 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
252 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
253 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
254 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
255 // rvalue is T
256 //
257 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000258 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
259 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000260 // type of the lvalue.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000262 }
263}
264
265
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000266/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000267/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000268/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
269/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
270/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
271Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
272 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
273 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000274
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000275 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
276 //
277 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
278 // unsigned int may be used:
279 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
280 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
281 // and unsigned int.
282 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
283 //
284 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
285 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
286 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
287 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000288 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
289 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000290 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000291 return Expr;
292 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000293 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000294 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000295 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000296 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000297 }
298
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000299 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000300 return Expr;
301}
302
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000303/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000304/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000305/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
306void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
307 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
308 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000309
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000310 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000311 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
312 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000313 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000314
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000315 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
316}
317
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000318/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
319/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
320/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
321/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000322bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
323 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000324 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000325
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000326 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
327 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
328 // etc.
329 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
330 return false;
331
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000332 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000333 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
334 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
335 << Expr->getType() << CT))
336 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000337
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000338 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000339 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000340 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
341 << Expr->getType() << CT))
342 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000343
344 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000345}
346
347
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000348/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
349/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000350/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000351/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
352/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
353/// GCC.
354QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
355 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000356 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000357 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000358
359 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000361 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000362 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000363 QualType lhs =
364 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000365 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000366 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000367
368 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
369 if (lhs == rhs)
370 return lhs;
371
372 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
373 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
374 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
375 return lhs;
376
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000377 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000378 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000379 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
380 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000381 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000382 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
383 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
384
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000385 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000386 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000387 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
388 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000389 return destType;
390}
391
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000392//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
393// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
394//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
395
396
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000397/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000398/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
399/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
400/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
401/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000402///
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000403ExprResult
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000404Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000405 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
406
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000407 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000408 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000409 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000410
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000411 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000412 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
413 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000414
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000415 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000416 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000417 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000418
419 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000420 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000421 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000422
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000423 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
424 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
425 // strings.
426 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000427 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000428 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000429
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000430 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000431 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
432 Literal.GetStringLength(),
433 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
434 &StringTokLocs[0],
435 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000436}
437
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000438/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
439/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
440/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
441/// for values inside the block or for globals).
442///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000443/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000444/// up-to-date.
445///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000446static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000447 ValueDecl *VD) {
448 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
449 // we wanted to.
450 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000453 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
454 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
455 return false;
456
457 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
458 // snapshot it.
459 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
460 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000461 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
462 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000463
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000464 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
465 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
466
467 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
468 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
469 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
470 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000471 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
472 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000473
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000474 if (!NextBlock)
475 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000476
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000477 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
478 // having a reference outside it.
479 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
480 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000481
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000482 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
483 // a snapshot as well.
484 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
485 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000486
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000487 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000488}
489
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000490
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000491ExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000492Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000493 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000494 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
495 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
496}
497
498/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000499ExprResult
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000500Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
501 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
502 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000503 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000504 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000505 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000506 << D->getDeclName();
507 return ExprError();
508 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000509
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000510 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000511 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
512 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
513 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000514 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000515 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000516 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
517 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000518 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
519 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000520 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000521 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000522 << D->getIdentifier();
523 return ExprError();
524 }
525 }
526 }
527 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000528
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000529 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000530
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000531 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
532 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
533 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000534 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000535}
536
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000537/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
538/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
539/// actual member.
540///
541/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
542/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
543/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
544/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
545/// we found.
546///
547/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
548/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
549/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
550VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
551 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000552 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
553 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
554 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
555
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000556 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000557 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
558 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
559 do {
560 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000561 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000562 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000563 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000564 else {
565 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
566 break;
567 }
568 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000569 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000570 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000571
572 return BaseObject;
573}
574
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000575ExprResult
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000576Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
577 FieldDecl *Field,
578 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
579 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
580 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000581 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000582 AnonFields);
583
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
585 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
586 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
587 // found via name lookup.
588 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000589 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 if (BaseObject) {
591 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
592 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000593 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000594 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Devang Patele25b5f82010-10-12 23:23:25 +0000595 Loc);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000596 BaseQuals
597 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000598 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
599 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
600 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
601 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
602 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000603 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000604 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
605 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
606 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 BaseQuals
608 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000609 } else {
610 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
611 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
612 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000613 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
614 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000615 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000616 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000617 = Context.getTagDeclType(
618 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
619 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000620 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000621 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
622 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
623 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000624 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000625 MD->getThisType(Context),
626 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000627 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
628 }
629 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000630 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
631 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000632 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000633 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000634 }
635
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000636 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000637 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
638 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000639 }
640
641 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
642 // anonymous struct/union.
643 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000644 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000645 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
646 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
647 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
648 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000649 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
650 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
651
652 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
653 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
654 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
655 ResultQuals.removeConst();
656
657 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
658 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
659
660 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
661 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
662
663 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
664 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
665 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
666
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000667 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000668 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000669 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000670 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
671 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000672 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000673 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000674 }
675
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000676 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000677}
678
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000679/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000680/// possibly a list of template arguments.
681///
682/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
683/// DecomposeTemplateName.
684///
685/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
686/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
687/// some way.
688static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
689 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
690 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000691 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000692 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
693 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
694 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
695 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
696
697 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
698 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
699 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
700 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
701 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
702
John McCall3e56fd42010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000703 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000704 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
705 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000706 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
707 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000708 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000709 TemplateArgs = 0;
710 }
711}
712
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000713/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
714/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
715/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000716static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000717 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
718 return false;
719
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000720 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
721 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
722 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
723 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
724 if (!BaseRT) return false;
725
726 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000727 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000728 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
729 return false;
730 }
731
732 return true;
733}
734
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000735/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
736/// the prospective base classes.
737static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
738 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
739 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000740 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000741 return false;
742
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000743 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000744 if (!RD) return false;
745 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
746
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000747 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
748 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
749 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
750 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
751 if (!BaseRT) return false;
752
753 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000754 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
755 return false;
756 }
757
758 return true;
759}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000760
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000761enum IMAKind {
762 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
763 IMA_Static,
764
765 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
766 IMA_Mixed,
767
768 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
769 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
770 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
771
772 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
773 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
774 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
775
776 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
777 IMA_Instance,
778
779 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
780 IMA_Unresolved,
781
782 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
783 /// context is not an instance method.
784 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
785
786 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
787 /// non-class context.
788 IMA_AnonymousMember,
789
790 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
791 /// context is not an instance method.
792 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
793
794 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
795 /// class.
796 IMA_Error_Unrelated
797};
798
799/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
800/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
801/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
802/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
803/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
804/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
805static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
806 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000807 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000808
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000809 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000810 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000811 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
812 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000813
814 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
815 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
816
817 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
818 bool hasNonInstance = false;
819 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
820 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000821 NamedDecl *D = *I;
822 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000823 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
824
825 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
826 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
827 // that's a special case.
828 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
829 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
830 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
831 }
832 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
833 }
834 else
835 hasNonInstance = true;
836 }
837
838 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
839 // member reference.
840 if (Classes.empty())
841 return IMA_Static;
842
843 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
844 // an implicit member reference.
845 if (isStaticContext)
846 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
847
848 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
849 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
850 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
851 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000852 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000853 Classes))
854 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
855
856 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
857}
858
859/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
860static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
861 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
862 const LookupResult &R) {
863 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
864 SourceRange Range(Loc);
865 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
866
867 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
868 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
869 if (MD->isStatic()) {
870 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
871 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
872 << Range << R.getLookupName();
873 return;
874 }
875 }
876
877 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
878 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
879 return;
880 }
881
882 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000883}
884
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000885/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
886///
887/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000888bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
889 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000890 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
891
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000892 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000893 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000894 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
895 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000896 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000897 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000898 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
899 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000900
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000901 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
902 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
903 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
904 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000905 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000906 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000907 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
908 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
909
910 if (!R.empty()) {
911 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
912 R.suppressDiagnostics();
913
914 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
915 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
916 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
917 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
918
919 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
920 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
921 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000922 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000923 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
924 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000925 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000926 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000927 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000928 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
929 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
930 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
931 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
932 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
933 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
934 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
935 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
936 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
937 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
938 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
939 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
940 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
941 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000942 } else {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000943 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
944 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
945 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000946 }
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000947 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000948 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000949 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000950
951 // Do we really want to note all of these?
952 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
953 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
954
955 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
956 return false;
957 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000958
959 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000960 }
961 }
962
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000963 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000964 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000965 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000966 if (!R.empty()) {
967 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
968 if (SS.isEmpty())
969 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
970 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
971 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
972 else
973 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
974 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
975 << SS.getRange()
976 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
977 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
978 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
979 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
980 << ND->getDeclName();
981
982 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
983 return false;
984 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000985
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000986 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
987 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
988 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
989 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
990 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
991 // to recover well anyway.
992 if (SS.isEmpty())
993 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
994 else
995 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
996 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
997 << SS.getRange();
998
999 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1000 return true;
1001 }
1002 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001003 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001004 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001005 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001006 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001007 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001008 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001009 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1010 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001011 return true;
1012 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001013 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001014 }
1015
1016 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1017 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1018 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1019 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1020 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1021 << SS.getRange();
1022 return true;
1023 }
1024
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001025 // Give up, we can't recover.
1026 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1027 return true;
1028}
1029
Douglas Gregor05fcf842010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001030ObjCPropertyDecl *Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(IdentifierInfo *II) {
1031 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001032 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1033 if (!IDecl)
1034 return 0;
1035 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1036 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1037 return 0;
Douglas Gregor05fcf842010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001038 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001039 if (!property)
1040 return 0;
1041 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
Douglas Gregor05fcf842010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001042 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1043 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001044 return 0;
1045 return property;
1046}
1047
Douglas Gregor05fcf842010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001048bool Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(ObjCPropertyDecl *Property) {
1049 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
1050 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1051 if (!IDecl)
1052 return false;
1053 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1054 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1055 return false;
1056 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl
1057 = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(Property->getIdentifier()))
1058 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1059 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1060 return false;
1061
1062 return true;
1063}
1064
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001065static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001066 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001067 IdentifierInfo *II,
1068 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1069 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001070 bool LookForIvars;
1071 if (Lookup.empty())
1072 LookForIvars = true;
1073 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1074 LookForIvars = false;
1075 else
1076 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1077 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1078 if (!LookForIvars)
1079 return 0;
1080
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001081 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1082 if (!IDecl)
1083 return 0;
1084 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001085 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1086 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001087 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1088 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1089 if (!property)
1090 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianbfcbc852010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001091 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II)) {
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001092 DynamicImplSeen =
1093 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
Fariborz Jahanianbfcbc852010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001094 // property implementation has a designated ivar. No need to assume a new
1095 // one.
1096 if (!DynamicImplSeen && PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1097 return 0;
1098 }
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001099 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001100 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1101 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001102 NameLoc,
1103 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1104 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1105 (Expr *)0, true);
1106 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1107 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1108 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1109 return Ivar;
1110 }
1111 return 0;
1112}
1113
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001114ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001115 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1116 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1117 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1118 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001119 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1120 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1121
1122 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001123 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001124
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001125 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001126
1127 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001128 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001129 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001130 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001131
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001132 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001133 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001134 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001135
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001136 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1137 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001138 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1139 // (note: handled after lookup)
1140 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1141 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1142 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001143 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1144 // names a dependent type.
1145 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1146 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001147 bool DependentID = false;
1148 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1149 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1150 DependentID = true;
1151 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1152 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1153 if (DC) {
1154 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1155 return ExprError();
1156 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1157 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1158 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1159 } else {
1160 DependentID = true;
1161 }
1162 }
1163
1164 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001165 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001166 TemplateArgs);
1167 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001168 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001169 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001170 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001171 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001172 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1173 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1174 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1175 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1176 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001177 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1178 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1179 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001180 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001181 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001182 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001183
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001184 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1185 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001186 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001187 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001188 if (E.isInvalid())
1189 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001190
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001191 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1192 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001193 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1194 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001195 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001196 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1197 isAddressOfOperand);
1198 }
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001199 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1200 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001201 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001202 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001203
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001204 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1205 return ExprError();
1206
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001207 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1208 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001209 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001210
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001211 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001212 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001213 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1214 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1215 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1216 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1217 }
1218
1219 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1220 // call, diagnose the problem.
1221 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001222 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001223 return ExprError();
1224
1225 assert(!R.empty() &&
1226 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001227
1228 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1229 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001230 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001231 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1232 R.clear();
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001233 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001234 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1235 return move(E);
1236 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001237 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001238 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001239
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001240 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1241 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1242
1243 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001244 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001245 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1246 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor05fcf842010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001247 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property = canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(II);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001248 if (Property) {
1249 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1250 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001251 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001252 }
1253 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001254 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001255 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1256 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1257 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1258 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1259 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1260 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001261 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001262 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001263
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001264 QualType T = Func->getType();
1265 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001266 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001267 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1268 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001269 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001270 }
1271 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001272
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001273 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001274 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1275 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1276 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1277 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1278 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1279 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1280 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1281 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001282 //
1283 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1284 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1285 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1286 // non-static member function:
1287 //
1288 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1289 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1290 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1291 // member function call.
1292 //
1293 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1294 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1295 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1296 // instance method.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001297 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001298 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1299 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1300 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1301 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1302 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1303 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1304 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregor1262b062010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001305 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1306 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001307 else
1308 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1309
1310 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001311 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001312 }
1313
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001314 if (TemplateArgs)
1315 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001316
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001317 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1318}
1319
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001320/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001321ExprResult
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001322Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1323 LookupResult &R,
1324 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1325 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1326 case IMA_Instance:
1327 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1328
1329 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1330 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1331 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1332 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1333
1334 case IMA_Mixed:
1335 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1336 case IMA_Unresolved:
1337 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1338
1339 case IMA_Static:
1340 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1341 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1342 if (TemplateArgs)
1343 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1344 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1345
1346 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1347 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1348 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1349 return ExprError();
1350 }
1351
1352 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1353 return ExprError();
1354}
1355
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001356/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1357/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1358/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1359/// this path.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001360ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001361Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001362 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001363 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001364 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001365 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001366
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001367 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001368 return ExprError();
1369
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001370 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001371 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1372
1373 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1374 return ExprError();
1375
1376 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001377 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1378 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001379 return ExprError();
1380 }
1381
1382 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1383}
1384
1385/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1386/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1387/// additional lookup.
1388///
1389/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1390/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1391///
1392/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001393ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001394Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001395 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001396 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001397 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001398
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001399 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1400 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1401 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1402 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1403 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1404
1405 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1406 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1407 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001408 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001409
1410 bool LookForIvars;
1411 if (Lookup.empty())
1412 LookForIvars = true;
1413 else if (IsClassMethod)
1414 LookForIvars = false;
1415 else
1416 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1417 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001418 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001419 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001420 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001421 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1422 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1423 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1424 if (IsClassMethod)
1425 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1426 << IV->getDeclName());
1427
1428 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1429 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1430 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1431 return ExprError();
1432
1433 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1434 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1435 return ExprError();
1436
1437 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1438 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1439 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1440 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1441
1442 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1443 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1444 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1445 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001446 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001447 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001448 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregora1ed39b2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001449 SelfName, false, false);
1450 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1451 return ExprError();
1452
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001453 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1454 return Owned(new (Context)
1455 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1456 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1457 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001458 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001459 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001460 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001461 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1462 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1463 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1464 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1465 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1466 }
1467 }
1468
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001469 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1470 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1471 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1472 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1473 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1474 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1475 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1476 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1477 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1478 }
1479 }
1480 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001481 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1482 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001483}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001484
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001485/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1486///
1487/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1488///
1489/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1490/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1491/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1492/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1493///
1494/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1495/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1496/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1497/// the class declaring the member.
1498///
1499/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1500/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1501/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001502bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001503Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1504 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001505 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001506 NamedDecl *Member) {
1507 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1508 if (!RD)
1509 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001510
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001511 QualType DestRecordType;
1512 QualType DestType;
1513 QualType FromRecordType;
1514 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1515 bool PointerConversions = false;
1516 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1517 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001518
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001519 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1520 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1521 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1522 PointerConversions = true;
1523 } else {
1524 DestType = DestRecordType;
1525 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001526 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001527 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1528 if (Method->isStatic())
1529 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001530
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001531 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1532 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001533
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001534 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1535 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1536 PointerConversions = true;
1537 } else {
1538 FromRecordType = FromType;
1539 DestType = DestRecordType;
1540 }
1541 } else {
1542 // No conversion necessary.
1543 return false;
1544 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001545
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001546 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1547 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001548
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001549 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1550 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1551 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001552
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001553 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1554 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1555
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001556 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001557
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001558 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001559 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001560 // class name.
1561 //
1562 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1563 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1564 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1565 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1566 //
1567 // class Base { public: int x; };
1568 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1569 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1570 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1571 //
1572 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1573 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1574 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1575 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001576 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001577 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1578 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1579 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1580
1581 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1582
1583 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1584 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1585 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1586 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001587 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001588 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001589 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001590 return true;
1591
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001592 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001593 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001594 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1595 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001596
1597 FromType = QType;
1598 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1599
1600 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1601 // we're done.
1602 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1603 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001604 }
1605 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001606
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001607 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001608
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001609 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1610 // down to the using declaration's type.
1611 //
1612 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1613 // class ever has member declarations.
1614 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1615 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1616 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1617 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1618
1619 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1620 // conversion is non-trivial.
1621 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1622 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001623 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001624 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001625 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001626 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001627
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001628 QualType UType = URecordType;
1629 if (PointerConversions)
1630 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001631 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001632 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001633 FromType = UType;
1634 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1635 }
1636
1637 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1638 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1639 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001640 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001641
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001642 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001643 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1644 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001645 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001646 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001647
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001648 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001649 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001650 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001651}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001652
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001653/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001654static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001655 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001656 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001657 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1658 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001659 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1660 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1661 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001662 if (SS.isSet()) {
1663 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1664 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001665 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001666
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001667 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001668 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1669 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001670}
1671
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001672/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1673/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1674/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1675/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001676ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001677Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1678 LookupResult &R,
1679 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1680 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001681 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1682
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001683 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001684
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001685 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1686 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001687 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001688 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001689 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001690 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001691 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001692
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001693 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1694 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001695 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1696 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001697 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1698 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001699 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1700 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1701 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1702 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001703 }
1704
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001705 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001706 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1707 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001708 SS,
1709 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1710 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001711}
1712
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001713bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001714 const LookupResult &R,
1715 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001716 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1717 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1718 return false;
1719
1720 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001721 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001722 return false;
1723
1724 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001725 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001726 return false;
1727
1728 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1729 // normal lookup:
1730 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1731 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1732
1733 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1734 // -- a declaration of a class member
1735 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1736 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001737 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001738 return false;
1739
1740 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1741 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1742 // using-declaration
1743 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1744 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1745 // turn off ADL anyway).
1746 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1747 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1748 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1749 return false;
1750
1751 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1752 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1753 // template
1754 // And also for builtin functions.
1755 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1756 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1757
1758 // But also builtin functions.
1759 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1760 return false;
1761 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1762 return false;
1763 }
1764
1765 return true;
1766}
1767
1768
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001769/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1770/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1771/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1772/// will in fact be used.
1773static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1774 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1775 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1776 return true;
1777 }
1778
1779 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1780 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1781 return true;
1782 }
1783
1784 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1785 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1786 return true;
1787 }
1788
1789 return false;
1790}
1791
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001792ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001793Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001794 LookupResult &R,
1795 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001796 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1797 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001798 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001799 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1800 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001801
1802 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1803 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1804 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001805 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1806 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001807 return ExprError();
1808
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001809 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1810 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1811 // we've picked a target.
1812 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1813
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001814 bool Dependent
1815 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001816 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001817 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001818 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001819 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001820 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1821 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001822
1823 return Owned(ULE);
1824}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001825
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001826
1827/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001828ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001829Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001830 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1831 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001832 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001833 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1834 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001835
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001836 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001837 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1838 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001839
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001840 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1841 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1842 // a template argument list.
1843 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1844 << Template << SS.getRange();
1845 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1846 return ExprError();
1847 }
1848
1849 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1850 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1851 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001852 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001853 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001854 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001855 return ExprError();
1856 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001857
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001858 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1859 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1860 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1861 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001862 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001863 return ExprError();
1864
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001865 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1866 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001867 return ExprError();
1868
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001869 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1870 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1871 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1872 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001873 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001874 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1875 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1876 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001877 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001878 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001879 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1880 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1881 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1882 return ExprError();
1883 }
1884
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001885 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001886 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1887 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1888 return ExprError();
1889 }
1890
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001891 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001892 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001893 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001894 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001895 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001896 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1897 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001898 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001899
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001900 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001901 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001902 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1903 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001904 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001905 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1906 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1907 Expr *E = new (Context)
1908 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1909 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001910
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001911 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001912 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001913 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001914 SourceLocation(),
1915 Owned(E));
1916 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001917 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001918 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1919 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1920 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001921 }
1922 }
1923 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001924 }
1925 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1926 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001927
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001928 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1929 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001930}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001931
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001932ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001933 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001934 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001935
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001936 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001937 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001938 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1939 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1940 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001941 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001942
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001943 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1944 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001945
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001946 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001947 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1948 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001949 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001950 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001951 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001952 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001953
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001954 QualType ResTy;
1955 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1956 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1957 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001958 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001959
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001960 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001961 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001962 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1963 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001964 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001965}
1966
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001967ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001968 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001969 bool Invalid = false;
1970 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1971 if (Invalid)
1972 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001973
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001974 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1975 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001976 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001977 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001978
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001979 QualType Ty;
1980 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1981 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1982 else if (Literal.isWide())
1983 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001984 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1985 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001986 else
1987 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001988
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001989 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1990 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001991 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001992}
1993
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001994ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001995 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001996 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1997 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001998 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001999 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002000 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00002001 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00002002 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00002003
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002004 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00002005 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
2006 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00002007 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002008
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002009 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002010 bool Invalid = false;
2011 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
2012 if (Invalid)
2013 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002014
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002015 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00002016 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00002017 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002018 return ExprError();
2019
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002020 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002021
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002022 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002023 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002024 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002025 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002026 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002027 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002028 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00002029 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002030
2031 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
2032
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002033 using llvm::APFloat;
2034 APFloat Val(Format);
2035
2036 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00002037
2038 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2039 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2040 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2041 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002042 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002043 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002044 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002045 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002046 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2047 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002048 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002049 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2050 }
2051
2052 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2053 << Ty
2054 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2055 }
2056
2057 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002058 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002059
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002060 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002061 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002062 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002063 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002064
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002065 // long long is a C99 feature.
2066 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002067 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002068 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2069
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002070 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002071 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002072
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002073 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2074 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2075 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002076 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2077 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002078 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002079 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002080 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2081 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002082
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002083 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2084 // be an unsigned int.
2085 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2086
2087 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002088 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002089 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2090 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002091 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002092
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002093 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2094 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2095 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2096 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002097 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002098 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002099 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002100 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002101 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002102 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002103
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002104 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002105 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002106 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002107
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002108 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2109 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2110 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2111 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002112 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002113 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002114 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002115 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002116 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002117 }
2118
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002119 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002120 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002121 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002122
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002123 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2124 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2125 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2126 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002127 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002128 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002129 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002130 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002131 }
2132 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002133
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002134 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2135 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002136 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002137 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002138 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002139 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002140 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002141
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002142 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2143 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002144 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002145 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002146 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002147
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002148 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2149 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002150 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002151 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002152
2153 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002154}
2155
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002156ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002157 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002158 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002159 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002160}
2161
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002162/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002163/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002164bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002165 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002166 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002167 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002168 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2169 return false;
2170
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002171 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2172 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2173 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2174 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2175 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2176 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2177
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002178 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002179 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002180 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002181 if (isSizeof)
2182 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2183 return false;
2184 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002185
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002186 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002187 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002188 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2189 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002190 return false;
2191 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002192
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002193 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002194 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2195 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002196 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002197
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002198 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002199 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002200 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002201 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2202 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002203 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002204
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002205 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002206}
2207
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002208static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2209 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002210 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002211
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002212 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002213 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2214 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002215
2216 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2217 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2218 return false;
2219
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002220 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002221 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002222 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002223 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002224
2225 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2226 // bit-field.
2227 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002228 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002229 return false;
2230
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002231 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002232}
2233
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002234/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002235ExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002236Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002237 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002238 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002239 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002240 return ExprError();
2241
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002242 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002243
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002244 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2245 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2246 return ExprError();
2247
2248 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002249 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002250 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2251 R.getEnd()));
2252}
2253
2254/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2255/// operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002256ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002257Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002258 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2259 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2260 bool isInvalid = false;
2261 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2262 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2263 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002264 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002265 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002266 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2267 isInvalid = true;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002268 } else if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
2269 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2270 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2271 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(PE.take(), OpLoc, isSizeOf, R);
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002272 } else {
2273 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2274 }
2275
2276 if (isInvalid)
2277 return ExprError();
2278
2279 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2280 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2281 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2282 R.getEnd()));
2283}
2284
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002285/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2286/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2287/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002288ExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002289Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2290 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002291 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002292 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002293
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002294 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002295 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002296 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002297 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002298 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002299
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002300 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002301 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002302 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2303
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002304 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002305}
2306
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002307QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002308 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2309 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002310
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002311 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002312 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002313 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002314
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002315 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2316 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2317 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002318
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002319 // Test for placeholders.
2320 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(V, Loc);
2321 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
2322 if (PR.take() != V) {
2323 V = PR.take();
2324 return CheckRealImagOperand(V, Loc, isReal);
2325 }
2326
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002327 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002328 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2329 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002330 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002331}
2332
2333
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002334
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002335ExprResult
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002336Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002337 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002338 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002339 switch (Kind) {
2340 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002341 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2342 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002343 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002344
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002345 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002346}
2347
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002348ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002349Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2350 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002351 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002352 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002353 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2354 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002355
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002356 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002357
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002358 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002359 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002360 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2361 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2362 }
2363
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002364 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002365 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002366 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2367 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2368 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002369 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002370 }
2371
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002372 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002373}
2374
2375
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002376ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002377Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2378 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2379 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2380 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002381
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002382 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002383 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2384 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2385 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002386
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002387 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002388
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002389 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002390 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002391 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002392 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002393 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2394 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002395 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2396 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2397 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2398 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002399 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002400 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2401 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002402 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002403 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002404 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002405 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2406 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002407 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002408 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002409 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002410 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2411 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2412 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002413 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002414 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002415 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2416 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2417 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2418 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002419 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002420 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002421 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002422
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002423 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2424 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002425 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2426 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002427 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002428 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2429 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2430 // force the promotion here.
2431 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2432 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002433 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002434 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002435 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2436
2437 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2438 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002439 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002440 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2441 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2442 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2443 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002444 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002445 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002446 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2447
2448 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2449 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002450 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002451 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002452 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2453 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002454 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002455 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002456 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002457 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2458 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002459
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002460 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002461 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2462 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002463 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2464
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002465 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002466 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2467 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002468 // incomplete types are not object types.
2469 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2470 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2471 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2472 return ExprError();
2473 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002474
Abramo Bagnara3aabb4b2010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002475 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2476 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2477 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2478 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2479 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002480 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002481 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2482 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002483 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002484
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002485 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002486 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002487 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2488 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2489 return ExprError();
2490 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002491
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002492 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002493 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002494}
2495
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002496QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002497CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002498 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002499 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002500 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2501 // see FIXME there.
2502 //
2503 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2504 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002505 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002506
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002507 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002508 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002509
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002510 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002511 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2512 // to be selected.
2513 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002514
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002515 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2516 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002517 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002518
2519 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2520 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002521 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002522 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2523 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002524 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002525 do
2526 compStr++;
2527 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002528 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002529 do
2530 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002531 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002532 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002533
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002534 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002535 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2536 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002537 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002538 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002539 return QualType();
2540 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002541
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002542 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2543 // operates on.
2544 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002545 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002546
2547 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002548 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002549
2550 while (*compStr) {
2551 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2552 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2553 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2554 return QualType();
2555 }
2556 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002557 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002558
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002559 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002560 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002561 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002562 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002563 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002564 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002565 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002566 if (HexSwizzle)
2567 CompSize--;
2568
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002569 if (CompSize == 1)
2570 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002571
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002572 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002573 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002574 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2575 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2576 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2577 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002578 }
2579 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002580}
2581
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002582static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002583 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002584 const Selector &Sel,
2585 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002586 if (Member)
2587 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
2588 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002589 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002590 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002591
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002592 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2593 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002594 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2595 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002596 return D;
2597 }
2598 return 0;
2599}
2600
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002601static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
2602 IdentifierInfo *Member,
2603 const Selector &Sel,
2604 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002605 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2606 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002607 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002608 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002609 if (Member)
2610 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
2611 GDecl = PD;
2612 break;
2613 }
2614 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002615 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002616 GDecl = OMD;
2617 break;
2618 }
2619 }
2620 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002621 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002622 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2623 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002624 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2625 Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002626 if (GDecl)
2627 return GDecl;
2628 }
2629 }
2630 return GDecl;
2631}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002632
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002633ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002634Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002635 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002636 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2637 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002638 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002639 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002640 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2641 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2642 //
2643 // T* t;
2644 // t.f;
2645 //
2646 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2647 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2648 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2649 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002650 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002651 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2652 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002653 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002654 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002655 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002656 return ExprError();
2657 }
2658 }
2659
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002660 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2661 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002662 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002663
2664 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2665 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002666 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002667 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002668 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002669 SS.getRange(),
2670 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002671 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002672}
2673
2674/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2675/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2676/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2677static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2678 Expr *BaseExpr,
2679 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002680 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002681 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002682 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2683 // diagnostics.
2684 if (!BaseExpr)
2685 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002686
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002687 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2688 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002689}
2690
2691// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2692// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2693// type. The restriction here is:
2694//
2695// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2696// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2697// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2698//
2699// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2700// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2701// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2702// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2703bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2704 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002705 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002706 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002707 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2708 if (!BaseRT) {
2709 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2710 // dependent.
2711 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2712 return false;
2713 }
2714 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002715
2716 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002717 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2718 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002719 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002720 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002721
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002722 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002723 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2724 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2725 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002726
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002727 if (!DC->isRecord())
2728 continue;
2729
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002730 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002731 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002732
2733 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2734 return false;
2735 }
2736
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002737 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002738 return true;
2739}
2740
2741static bool
2742LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2743 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002744 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2745 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002746 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2747 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002748 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002749 << BaseRange))
2750 return true;
2751
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002752 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2753 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2754 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2755
2756 bool MOUS;
2757 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2758 return false;
2759 }
2760
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002761 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2762 if (SS.isSet()) {
2763 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2764 // nested-name-specifier.
2765 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2766
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002767 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002768 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2769 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2770 return true;
2771 }
2772
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002773 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002774
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002775 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2776 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2777 << DC << SS.getRange();
2778 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002779 }
2780 }
2781
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002782 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2783 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002784
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002785 if (!R.empty())
2786 return false;
2787
2788 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2789 // for typos.
2790 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002791 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002792 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002793 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2794 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2795 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002796 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2797 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002798 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2799 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2800 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002801 return false;
2802 } else {
2803 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002804 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002805 }
2806
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002807 return false;
2808}
2809
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002810ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002811Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002812 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002813 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002814 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002815 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002816 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002817 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2818 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002819 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002820 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2821 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002822 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002823
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002824 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002825
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002826 // Implicit member accesses.
2827 if (!Base) {
2828 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2829 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2830 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2831 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002832 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002833 return ExprError();
2834
2835 // Explicit member accesses.
2836 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002837 ExprResult Result =
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002838 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002839 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002840
2841 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2842 Owned(Base);
2843 return ExprError();
2844 }
2845
2846 if (Result.get())
2847 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002848
2849 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2850 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002851 }
2852
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002853 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002854 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2855 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002856}
2857
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002858ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002859Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002860 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2861 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002862 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002863 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002864 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2865 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002866 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002867 if (IsArrow) {
2868 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2869 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2870 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002871 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002872
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002873 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002874 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2875 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2876 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002877
2878 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002879 return ExprError();
2880
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002881 if (R.empty()) {
2882 // Rederive where we looked up.
2883 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2884 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2885 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002886
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002887 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002888 << MemberName << DC
2889 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002890 return ExprError();
2891 }
2892
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002893 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2894 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2895 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2896 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2897 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2898 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2899 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2900 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2901 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2902 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002903 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002904 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002905 return ExprError();
2906
2907 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2908 // result.
2909 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002910 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002911 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002912 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002913 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002914
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002915 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2916 // pick a member.
2917 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2918
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002919 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2920 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2921 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002922 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2923 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002924 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002925 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002926 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002927
2928 return Owned(MemExpr);
2929 }
2930
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002931 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002932 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002933 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2934
2935 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2936
2937 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2938 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2939 // error cases.
2940 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2941 return ExprError();
2942
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002943 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2944 if (!BaseExpr) {
2945 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002946 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002947 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002948
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002949 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2950 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2951 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2952 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002953 }
2954
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002955 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2956 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2957 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2958 // explicitly qualified.
2959 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2960 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2961 }
2962
2963 // Check the use of this member.
2964 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2965 Owned(BaseExpr);
2966 return ExprError();
2967 }
2968
2969 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2970 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2971 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002972 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2973 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002974 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2975 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2976
2977 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2978 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2979 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2980 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2981 else {
2982 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2983 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2984 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2985
2986 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2987 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2988
2989 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2990 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2991 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2992 }
2993
2994 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002995 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002996 return ExprError();
2997 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002998 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2999 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003000 }
3001
3002 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3003 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
3004 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003005 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003006 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
3007 }
3008
3009 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3010 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3011 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003012 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003013 MemberFn->getType()));
3014 }
3015
3016 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3017 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3018 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003019 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3020 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003021 }
3022
3023 Owned(BaseExpr);
3024
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003025 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003026 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003027 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003028 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
3029 else
3030 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
3031 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003032
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003033 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
3034 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003035 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003036 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003037}
3038
3039/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
3040/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
3041/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
3042/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
3043/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
3044/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
3045/// an ordinary member expression.
3046///
3047/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3048/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003049ExprResult
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003050Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003051 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003052 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003053 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003054 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003055
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003056 // Perform default conversions.
3057 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003058
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003059 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003060 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3061
3062 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3063 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003064
3065 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003066 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003067 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3068 // call, and continue on.
3069 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3070 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3071 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3072 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3073 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003074 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3075 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003076 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3077 ->isRecordType()))) {
3078 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
Nick Lewyckyc60d6e72010-10-15 21:43:24 +00003079 Diag(BaseExpr->getExprLoc(), diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003080 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003081 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003082
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003083 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003084 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003085 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003086 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003087 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003088
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003089 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3090 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3091 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3092 }
3093 }
3094 }
3095
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003096 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3097 // use that.
3098 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003099 if (IsArrow) {
3100 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3101 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3102 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003103 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003104 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003105 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3106 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003107 }
3108 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003109 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3110 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3111 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3112 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003113 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003114 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003115 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003116
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003117 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3118 // use that.
3119 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3120 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3121 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3122 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3123 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003124 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003125 }
3126 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003127
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003128 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003129
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003130 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003131 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003132 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3133 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3134 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3135 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3136 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3137 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3138 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3139 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3140 // Check the use of this method.
3141 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3142 return ExprError();
3143 }
3144 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3145 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3146 Selector SetterSel =
3147 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3148 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3149 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3150 if (!Setter) {
3151 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3152 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003153 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003154 }
3155 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3156 if (!Setter)
3157 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003158
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003159 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3160 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003161
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003162 if (Getter || Setter) {
3163 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003164
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003165 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003166 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003167 else
3168 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3169 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3170 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003171 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003172 PType,
3173 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3174 }
3175 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3176 << MemberName << BaseType);
3177 }
3178 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003179
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003180 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3181 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3182 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003183 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003184 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003185
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003186 if (IsArrow) {
3187 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003188 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003189 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3190 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003191 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3192 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3193 // struct MyRecord foo;
3194 // foo->bar
3195 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3196 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3197 // by now.
3198 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3199 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003200 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003201 IsArrow = false;
3202 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003203 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3204 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3205 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003206 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003207 } else {
3208 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3209 // type *foo;
3210 // foo.bar
3211 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3212 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3213 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3214 // the appropriate pointer type
3215 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3216 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3217 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3218 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3219 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003220 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003221 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3222 IsArrow = true;
3223 }
3224 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003225 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003226
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003227 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003228 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003229 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003230 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003231 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003232 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003233 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003234
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003235 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3236 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003237 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003238 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003239 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003240 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3241 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3242 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3243 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003244 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3245
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003246 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003247 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003248
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003249 if (!IV) {
3250 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3251 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3252 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregord507d772010-10-20 03:06:34 +00003253 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false,
3254 IsArrow? CTC_ObjCIvarLookup
3255 : CTC_ObjCPropertyLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003256 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003257 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003258 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3259 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003260 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3261 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003262 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003263 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003264 } else {
3265 Res.clear();
3266 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003267 }
3268 }
3269
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003270 if (IV) {
3271 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3272 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3273 // error cases.
3274 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3275 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003276
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003277 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3278 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3279 return ExprError();
3280 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3281 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3282 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3283 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3284 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3285 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3286 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3287 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3288 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3289 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3290 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3291 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003292 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003293 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003294 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3295 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003296 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003297 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3298 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003299
3300 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3301 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003302 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003303 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003304 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003305 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3306 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003307 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003308 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003309 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003310
3311 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3312 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003313 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003314 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003315 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003316 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003317 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003318 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003319 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003320 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003321 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3322 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003323 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003324 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003325
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003326 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003327 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003328 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel,
3329 Context)) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003330 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3331 // Check the use of this declaration
3332 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3333 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003334
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003335 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003336 MemberLoc,
3337 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003338 }
3339 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3340 // Check the use of this method.
3341 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3342 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003343 Selector SetterSel =
3344 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3345 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3346 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3347 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, /*Property id*/0,
3348 SetterSel, Context))
3349 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3350 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3351 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(OMD, PType,
3352 SMD,
3353 MemberLoc,
3354 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003355 }
3356 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003357
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003358 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003359 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003360 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003361
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003362 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3363 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003364 if (!IsArrow)
3365 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3366 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003367 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc,
3368 SourceLocation(), QualType(), false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003369
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003370 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003371 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003372 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3373 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003374 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003375 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003376 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003377
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003378 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003379 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003380 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003381 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3382 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003383 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003384 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003385 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003386 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003387
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003388 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3389 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3390
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003391 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003392}
3393
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003394/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3395/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3396/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3397/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3398/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3399///
3400/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3401/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3402/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3403/// only be called
3404/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3405/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3406/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003407ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003408 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3409 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003410 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003411 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003412 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003413 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3414 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3415 return ExprError();
3416
3417 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3418
3419 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003420 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003421 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3422 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003423 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003424
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003425 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003426 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3427
3428 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3429 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3430 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3431
3432 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003433 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003434 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3435 Base = Result.take();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003436
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003437 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3438 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003439 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003440 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3441 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003442 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003443 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003444 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003445 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3446 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003447
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003448 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3449 Owned(Base);
3450 return ExprError();
3451 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003452
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003453 if (Result.get()) {
3454 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3455 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3456 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3457 // call now.
3458 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3459 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003460 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003461
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003462 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003463 }
3464
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003465 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003466 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3467 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003468 }
3469
3470 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003471}
3472
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003473ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003474 FunctionDecl *FD,
3475 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3476 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003477 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003478 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3479 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003480 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003481 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003482 return ExprError();
3483 }
3484
3485 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3486 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003487
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003488 // Instantiate the expression.
3489 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3490 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003491
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003492 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3493 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3494 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3495 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003496
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003497 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3498 if (Result.isInvalid())
3499 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003500
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003501 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3502 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003503 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003504 InitializationKind Kind
3505 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3506 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3507 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003508
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003509 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3510 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3511 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3512 if (Result.isInvalid())
3513 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003514
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003515 // Build the default argument expression.
3516 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3517 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003518 }
3519
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003520 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3521 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3522 // be properly destroyed.
3523 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3524 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003525 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3526 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3527 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3528 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3529 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3530 }
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003531
3532 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003533 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3534 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003535 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003536 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003537}
3538
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003539/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3540/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3541/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3542/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3543/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3544/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003545bool
3546Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003547 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003548 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003549 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3550 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003551 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003552 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3553 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003554 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003555
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003556 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3557 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3558 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3559 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3560 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003561 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003562 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003563 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003564 }
3565
3566 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3567 // them.
3568 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3569 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3570 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3571 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003572 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003573 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003574 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3575 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3576 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003577 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003578 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003579 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003580 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003581 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003582 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003583 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3584 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3585 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3586 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3587 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003588 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003589 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003590 if (Invalid)
3591 return true;
3592 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3593 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3594 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003595
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003596 return false;
3597}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003598
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003599bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3600 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3601 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3602 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3603 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3604 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003605 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003606 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3607 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3608 bool Invalid = false;
3609 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3610 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3611 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3612 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003613 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003614 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003615 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003616
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003617 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003618 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3619 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003620
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003621 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3622 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003623 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003624 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003625 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003626
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003627 // Pass the argument
3628 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3629 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3630 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003631
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003632 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003633 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3634 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003635 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003636 SourceLocation(),
3637 Owned(Arg));
3638 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3639 return true;
3640
3641 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003642 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003643 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003644
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003645 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003646 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003647 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3648 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003649
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003650 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003651 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003652 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003653 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003654
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003655 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003656 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003657 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003658 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003659 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003660 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003661 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003662 }
3663 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003664 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003665}
3666
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003667/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003668/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3669/// locations.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003670ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003671Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003672 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003673 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003674
3675 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003676 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003677 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3678 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003679
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003680 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003681
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003682 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003683 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3684 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3685 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3686 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3687 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003688 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003689 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3690 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003691
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003692 NumArgs = 0;
3693 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003694
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003695 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3696 RParenLoc));
3697 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003698
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003699 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003700 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003701 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3702 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003703 bool Dependent = false;
3704 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3705 Dependent = true;
3706 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3707 Dependent = true;
3708
3709 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003710 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003711 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3712
3713 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3714 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3715 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003716 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003717
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003718 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3719
3720 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3721 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3722 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3723 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3724 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3725 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3726 // method template.
3727 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003728 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3729 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003730 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003731
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003732 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003733 RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003734 }
3735
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003736 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003737 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003738 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003739 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003740 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003741 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003742 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003743
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003744 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003745 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003746 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3747 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003748 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3749 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003750 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003751
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003752 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3753 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3754 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3755 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003756
3757 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3758 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003759 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003760 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003761
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003762 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003763 RParenLoc))
3764 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003765
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003766 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003767 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003768 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003769 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3770 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003771 }
3772 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003773 }
3774
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003775 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003776 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003777 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003778
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003779 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003780 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3781 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003782 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003783 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003784 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003785
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003786 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
Douglas Gregor59f16ed2010-10-25 20:48:33 +00003787 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn))
3788 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
3789 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
3790
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003791 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3792 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3793
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003794 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3795}
3796
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003797/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3798/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003799/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3800/// block-pointer type.
3801///
3802/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003803ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003804Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3805 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3806 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3807 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3808 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3809
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003810 // Promote the function operand.
3811 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3812
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003813 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3814 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003815 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3816 Args, NumArgs,
3817 Context.BoolTy,
3818 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003819
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003820 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3821 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3822 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3823 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003824 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003825 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003826 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3827 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003828 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003829 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003830 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003831 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003832 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003833 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003834 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3835 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3836
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003837 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003838 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003839 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003840 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003841 return ExprError();
3842
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003843 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003844 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003845
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003846 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003847 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003848 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003849 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003850 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003851 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003852
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003853 if (FDecl) {
3854 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3855 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3856 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003857 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Douglas Gregor8e09a722010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003858 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
3859 = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3860 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size()))
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003861 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3862 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003863 }
Douglas Gregor8e09a722010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003864
3865 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
3866 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
3867 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
3868 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003869 }
3870
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003871 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003872 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3873 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Douglas Gregor8e09a722010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003874
3875 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumArgs()) {
Douglas Gregor8e09a722010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003876 InitializedEntity Entity
3877 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
3878 Proto->getArgType(i));
3879 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3880 SourceLocation(),
3881 Owned(Arg));
3882 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3883 return true;
3884
3885 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
3886
3887 } else {
3888 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Douglas Gregor8e09a722010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003889 }
3890
Douglas Gregor83025412010-10-26 05:45:40 +00003891 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3892 Arg->getType(),
3893 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3894 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
3895 return ExprError();
3896
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003897 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003898 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003899 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003900
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003901 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3902 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003903 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3904 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003905
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003906 // Check for sentinels
3907 if (NDecl)
3908 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003909
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003910 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003911 if (FDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003912 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003913 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003914
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003915 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003916 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003917 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003918 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003919 return ExprError();
3920 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003921
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003922 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003923}
3924
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003925ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003926Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003927 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003928 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003929 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003930 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003931
3932 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3933 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3934 if (!TInfo)
3935 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3936
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003937 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003938}
3939
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003940ExprResult
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003941Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003942 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003943 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003944
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003945 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003946 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003947 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3948 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003949 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3950 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003951 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003952 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003953 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003954 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003955
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003956 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003957 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003958 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003959 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003960 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003961 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003962 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003963 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003964 &literalType);
3965 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003966 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003967 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003968
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003969 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003970 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003971 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003972 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003973 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003974
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003975 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003976 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003977}
3978
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003979ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003980Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003981 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3982 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003983 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003984
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003985 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003986 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003987
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003988 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3989 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003990 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003991 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003992}
3993
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003994static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003995 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003996 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003997 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003998
3999 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
4000 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004001 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004002 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
4003 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004004 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004005 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004006 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004007
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004008 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
4009 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004010 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004011 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004012 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004013 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004014 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004015 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004016
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004017 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
4018 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004019 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004020 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004021 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004022 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004023
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004024 // FIXME: Assert here.
4025 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004026 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004027}
4028
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004029/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00004030bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004031 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004032 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00004033 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004034 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004035 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
4036 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004037
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004038 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004039
4040 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
4041 // type needs to be scalar.
4042 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
4043 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004044 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004045 return false;
4046 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004047
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00004048 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
4049 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
4050 return true;
4051
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004052 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004053 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004054 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
4055 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004056 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004057 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
4058 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004059 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004060 return false;
4061 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004062
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004063 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004064 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004065 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004066 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004067 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004068 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004069 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara5d3e7242010-10-07 21:20:44 +00004070 castExpr->getType()) &&
4071 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004072 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
4073 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4074 break;
4075 }
4076 }
4077 if (Field == FieldEnd)
4078 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4079 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004080 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004081 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004082 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004083
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004084 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4085 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4086 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4087 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004088
4089 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004090 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004091 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4092 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004093 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004094 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004095
4096 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004097 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004098
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004099 if (castType->isVectorType())
4100 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4101 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4102 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4103
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004104 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4105 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004106
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004107 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004108 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004109 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004110 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004111 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4112 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4113 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4114 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004115 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004116 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4117 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4118 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004119 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004120
4121 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004122
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004123 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004124 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4125
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004126 return false;
4127}
4128
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004129bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004130 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004131 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004132
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004133 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004134 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004135 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004136 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004137 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004138 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004139 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004140 } else
4141 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004142 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004143 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004144
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004145 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004146 return false;
4147}
4148
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004149bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004150 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004151 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004152
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004153 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004154
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004155 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4156 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004157 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4158 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4159 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4160 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004161 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004162 return false;
4163 }
4164
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004165 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004166 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4167 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004168 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4169 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4170 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4171 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004172
4173 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4174 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4175 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004176
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004177 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004178 return false;
4179}
4180
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004181ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004182Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004183 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4184 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004185 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004186
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004187 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4188 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4189 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004190 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004191
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004192 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4193 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004194 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004195 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004196
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004197 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004198}
4199
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004200ExprResult
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004201Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004202 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004203 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004204 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004205 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004206 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004207 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004208
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004209 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004210 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004211 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4212 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004213}
4214
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004215/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4216/// of comma binary operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004217ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004218Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004219 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4220 if (!E)
4221 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004222
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004223 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004224
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004225 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004226 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4227 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004228
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004229 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4230
4231 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004232}
4233
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004234ExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004235Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004236 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004237 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004238 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004239 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004240 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004241
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004242 // Check for an altivec literal,
4243 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004244 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4245 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4246 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4247 return ExprError();
4248 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004249 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4250 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4251 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4252 }
4253 else
4254 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4255 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004256
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004257 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4258 // then handle it as such.
4259 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004260 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4261 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4262 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4263
4264 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4265 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004266 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4267 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004268 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4269 E->setType(Ty);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004270 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004271 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004272 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004273 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004274 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004275 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4276 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004277 }
4278}
4279
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004280ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004281 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004282 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004283 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004284 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4285 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004286 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4287 Expr *expr;
4288 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4289 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4290 else
4291 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004292 return Owned(expr);
4293}
4294
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004295/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4296/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004297/// C99 6.5.15
4298QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004299 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004300 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004301 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4302 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004303 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004304
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004305 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004306 if (SAVE) {
4307 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4308 }
4309 else
4310 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004311 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4312 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4313 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4314 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004315
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004316 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004317 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begemanabb5a732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004318 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4319 // Throw an error if its not either.
4320 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4321 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4322 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4323 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4324 << CondTy;
4325 return QualType();
4326 }
4327 }
4328 else {
4329 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4330 << CondTy;
4331 return QualType();
4332 }
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004333 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004334
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004335 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004336 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4337 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004338
Nate Begemanabb5a732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004339 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4340 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4341 // built in select.
4342 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4343 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4344 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4345 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4346 << CondTy;
4347 return QualType();
4348 }
4349 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4350 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4351 << CondTy;
4352 return QualType();
4353 }
4354 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4355 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4356 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4357 }
4358
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004359 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4360 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004361 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4362 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4363 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004364 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004365
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004366 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4367 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004368 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4369 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004370 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004371 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004372 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004373 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004374 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004375 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004376
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004377 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004378 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004379 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4380 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4381 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4382 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4383 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4384 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4385 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004386 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4387 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004388 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004389 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004390 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4391 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004392 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004393 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004394 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004395 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004396 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004397 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004398 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004399 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004400 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004401 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004402 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004403
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004404 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4405 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4406 QuestionLoc);
4407 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4408 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004409
4410
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004411 // Handle block pointer types.
4412 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4413 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4414 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4415 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004416 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4417 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004418 return destType;
4419 }
4420 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004421 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004422 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004423 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004424 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4425 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4426 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004427 return LHSTy;
4428 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004429 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004430 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4431 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004432
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004433 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4434 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004435 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004436 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004437 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4438 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4439 // to get a consistent AST.
4440 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004441 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4442 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004443 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004444 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004445 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004446 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4447 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004448 return LHSTy;
4449 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004450
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004451 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4452 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4453 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004454 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4455 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004456
4457 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4458 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4459 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004460 QualType destPointee
4461 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004462 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004463 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004464 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004465 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004466 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004467 return destType;
4468 }
4469 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004470 QualType destPointee
4471 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004472 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004473 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004474 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004475 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004476 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004477 return destType;
4478 }
4479
4480 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4481 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4482 return LHSTy;
4483 }
4484 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4485 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4486 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4487 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4488 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4489 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4490 // to get a consistent AST.
4491 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004492 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4493 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004494 return incompatTy;
4495 }
4496 // The pointer types are compatible.
4497 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4498 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4499 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4500 // type.
4501 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4502 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004503 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4504 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004505 return LHSTy;
4506 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004507
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004508 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4509 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4510 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4511 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004512 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004513 return RHSTy;
4514 }
4515 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4516 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4517 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004518 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004519 return LHSTy;
4520 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004521
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004522 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004523 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4524 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004525 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004526}
4527
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004528/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4529/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4530QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4531 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4532 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4533 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004534
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004535 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4536 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4537 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4538 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4539 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004540 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004541 return LHSTy;
4542 }
4543 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4544 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004545 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004546 return RHSTy;
4547 }
4548 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4549 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4550 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004551 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004552 return LHSTy;
4553 }
4554 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4555 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004556 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004557 return RHSTy;
4558 }
4559 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4560 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4561 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004562 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004563 return LHSTy;
4564 }
4565 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4566 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004567 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004568 return RHSTy;
4569 }
4570 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4571 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004572
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004573 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4574 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4575 return LHSTy;
4576 }
4577 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4578 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4579 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004580
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004581 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4582 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4583 // type. This allows
4584 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4585 // where B is a subclass of A.
4586 //
4587 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4588 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4589 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4590 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004591
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004592 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4593 // It could return the composite type.
4594 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4595 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4596 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4597 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4598 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4599 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4600 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4601 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4602 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4603 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4604 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4605 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4606 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4607 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004608 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004609 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4610 ;
4611 else {
4612 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4613 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4614 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4615 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004616 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4617 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004618 return incompatTy;
4619 }
4620 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004621 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4622 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004623 return compositeType;
4624 }
4625 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4626 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4627 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4628 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4629 QualType destPointee
4630 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4631 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4632 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004633 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004634 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004635 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004636 return destType;
4637 }
4638 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4639 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4640 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4641 QualType destPointee
4642 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4643 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4644 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004645 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004646 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004647 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004648 return destType;
4649 }
4650 return QualType();
4651}
4652
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004653/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004654/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004655ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004656 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004657 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4658 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004659 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4660 // was the condition.
4661 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004662 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4663 if (isLHSNull) {
4664 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4665 }
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004666
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004667 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4668 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004669 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004670 return ExprError();
4671
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004672 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004673 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4674 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4675 result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004676}
4677
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004678// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004679// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004680// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4681// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4682// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004683Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004684Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004685 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004686
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004687 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4688 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4689 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4690 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4691 return Compatible;
4692 }
4693
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004694 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004695 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4696 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004697
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004698 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004699 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4700 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004701
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004702 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004703
4704 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4705 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4706 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004707 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004708 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004709 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004710
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004711 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4712 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004713 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004714 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004715 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004716 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004717
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004718 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004719 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4720 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004721 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004722
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004723 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004724 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004725 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004726
4727 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004728 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4729 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004730 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004731 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004732 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004733 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4734 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4735 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4736 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4737 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4738 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004739 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004740 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004741 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004742 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004743
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004744 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004745 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004746 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004747 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004748
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004749 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4750 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4751 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4752 // warning can be disabled.
4753 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4754 return ConvTy;
4755 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4756 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004757
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004758 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4759 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4760 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4761 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4762 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4763 do {
4764 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4765 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004766
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004767 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4768 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4769 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004770
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004771 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004772 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004773 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004774
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004775 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004776 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004777 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004778 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004779}
4780
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004781/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4782/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4783/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4784// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004785Sema::AssignConvertType
4786Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004787 QualType rhsType) {
4788 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004789
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004790 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004791 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4792 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004793
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004794 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4795 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4796 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004797
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004798 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004799
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004800 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004801 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004802 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004803
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004804 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4805 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4806 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4807 }
4808 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004809 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004810 return ConvTy;
4811}
4812
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004813/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4814/// for assignment compatibility.
4815Sema::AssignConvertType
4816Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004817 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4818 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004819 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4820 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004821 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004822 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004823 }
4824 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4825 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004826 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4827 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004828 return IncompatiblePointer;
4829 return Compatible;
4830 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004831 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004832 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004833 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004834 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4835 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4836 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4837 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4838 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4839 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004840
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004841 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4842 return Compatible;
4843 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4844 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004845 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004846}
4847
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004848/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4849/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004850/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4851///
4852/// int a, *pint;
4853/// short *pshort;
4854/// struct foo *pfoo;
4855///
4856/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4857/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4858/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4859/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4860///
4861/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004862/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004863///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004864Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004865Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004866 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4867 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004868 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4869 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004870
4871 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004872 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004873
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004874 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4875 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4876 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4877 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4878 return Compatible;
4879 }
4880
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004881 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4882 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4883 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4884 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4885 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4886 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4887 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004888 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004889 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004890 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004891 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004892 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004893 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4894 // to the same ExtVector type.
4895 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4896 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4897 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004898 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004899 return Compatible;
4900 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004901
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004902 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004903 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4904 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4905 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4906 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4907 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4908 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004909 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004910
4911 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4912 // vector type and vice versa
4913 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4914 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004915 }
4916 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004917 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004918
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004919 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4920 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004921 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004922
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004923 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004924 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004925 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004926
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004927 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004928 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004929
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004930 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004931 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004932 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4933 return Compatible;
4934 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004935 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004936 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4937 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004938 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004939
4940 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004941 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004942 return Compatible;
4943 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004944 return Incompatible;
4945 }
4946
4947 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4948 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004949 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004950
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004951 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004952 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004953 return Compatible;
4954
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004955 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4956 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004957
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004958 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004959 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004960 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004961 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004962 return Incompatible;
4963 }
4964
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004965 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4966 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4967 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004968
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004969 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004970 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004971 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4972 return Compatible;
4973 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004974 }
4975 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004976 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004977 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004978 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004979 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4980 return Compatible;
4981 }
4982 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4983 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4984 return Compatible;
4985 return Incompatible;
4986 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004987 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004988 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004989 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4990 return Compatible;
4991
4992 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004993 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004994
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004995 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004996 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004997
4998 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004999 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005000 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005001 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005002 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005003 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
5004 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
5005 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
5006 return Compatible;
5007
5008 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
5009 return PointerToInt;
5010
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005011 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005012 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005013 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5014 return Compatible;
5015 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005016 }
5017 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005018 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005019 return Compatible;
5020 return Incompatible;
5021 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005022
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005023 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005024 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005025 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00005026 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005027 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00005028}
5029
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005030/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
5031/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005032static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005033 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
5034 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
5035 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00005036 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00005037 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005038 SourceLocation());
5039 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
5040 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
5041
5042 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
5043 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005044 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00005045 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005046 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005047}
5048
5049Sema::AssignConvertType
5050Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
5051 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
5052
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005053 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005054 // transparent_union GCC extension.
5055 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005056 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005057 return Incompatible;
5058
5059 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
5060 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
5061 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
5062 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005063 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
5064 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005065 it != itend; ++it) {
5066 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
5067 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
5068 // 1) void pointer
5069 // 2) null pointer constant
5070 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005071 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005072 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005073 InitField = *it;
5074 break;
5075 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005076
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005077 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005078 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005079 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005080 InitField = *it;
5081 break;
5082 }
5083 }
5084
5085 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
5086 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar60785eb2010-09-17 23:21:43 +00005087 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005088 InitField = *it;
5089 break;
5090 }
5091 }
5092
5093 if (!InitField)
5094 return Incompatible;
5095
5096 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5097 return Compatible;
5098}
5099
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005100Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005101Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005102 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5103 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5104 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5105 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5106 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005107 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005108 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005109 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005110 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005111 }
5112
5113 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5114 // structures.
5115 }
5116
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005117 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5118 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005119 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5120 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005121 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005122 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005123 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005124 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005125 return Compatible;
5126 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005127
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005128 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005129 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005130 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005131 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005132 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005133 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005134 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005135 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005136
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005137 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5138 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005139
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005140 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5141 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005142 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5143 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5144 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5145 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005146 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005147 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005148 CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005149 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005150}
5151
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005152QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005153 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005154 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005155 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005156 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00005157}
5158
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005159QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005160 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005161 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005162 QualType lhsType =
5163 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5164 QualType rhsType =
5165 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005166
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005167 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005168 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005169 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005170
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005171 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5172 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005173 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005174 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005175 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005176 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005177 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005178 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005179 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005180 return lhsType;
5181 }
5182
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005183 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005184 return rhsType;
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005185 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5186 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5187 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5188 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5189 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5190 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005191 }
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005192 }
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005193 }
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005194 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005195
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005196 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5197 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5198 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005199 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005200 return rhsType;
5201 }
5202
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005203 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5204 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5205 bool swapped = false;
5206 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5207 swapped = true;
5208 std::swap(rex, lex);
5209 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5210 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005211
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005212 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005213 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005214 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005215 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005216 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005217 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005218 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5219 return lhsType;
5220 }
5221 }
5222 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5223 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5224 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005225 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005226 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5227 return lhsType;
5228 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005229 }
5230 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005231
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005232 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005233 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005234 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005235 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005236 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005237}
5238
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005239QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5240 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005241 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005242 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005243
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005244 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005245
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005246 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5247 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5248 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005249
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005250 // Check for division by zero.
5251 if (isDiv &&
5252 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005253 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005254 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005255
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005256 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005257}
5258
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005259QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005260 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005261 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005262 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5263 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005264 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5265 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5266 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005267
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005268 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005269
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005270 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5271 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005272
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005273 // Check for remainder by zero.
5274 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005275 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5276 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005277
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005278 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005279}
5280
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005281QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005282 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005283 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5284 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5285 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5286 return compType;
5287 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005288
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005289 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005290
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005291 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005292 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5293 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5294 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005295 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005296 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005297
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005298 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5299 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005300 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005301 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5302
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005303 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005304
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005305 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005306 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005307
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005308 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5309 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005310 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5311 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005312 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005313 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005314 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005315
5316 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5317 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5318 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005319 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005320 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5321 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5322 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5323 return QualType();
5324 }
5325
5326 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5327 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5328 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005329 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005330 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005331 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005332 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005333 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5334 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005335 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5336 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005337 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005338 return QualType();
5339 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005340 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005341 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005342 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5343 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5344 return QualType();
5345 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005346
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005347 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005348 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5349 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5350 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5351 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5352 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005353 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005354 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5355 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005356 return PExp->getType();
5357 }
5358 }
5359
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005360 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005361}
5362
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005363// C99 6.5.6
5364QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005365 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5366 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5367 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5368 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5369 return compType;
5370 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005371
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005372 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005373
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005374 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005375
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005376 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005377 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5378 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005379 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005380 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005381 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005382
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005383 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005384 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005385 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005386
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005387 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005388
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005389 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5390 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5391 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5392 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5393 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5394 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5395 return QualType();
5396 }
5397
5398 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5399 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5400 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5401 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5402 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005403 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005404 return QualType();
5405 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005406
5407 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5408 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5409 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005410 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005411 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005412 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005413 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005414 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005415
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005416 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005417 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005418 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5419 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5420 return QualType();
5421 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005422
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005423 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005424 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5425 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5426 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5427 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5428 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5429 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005430 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005431 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5432
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005433 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005434 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005435 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005436
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005437 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005438 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005439 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005440
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005441 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5442 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5443 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5444 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5445 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5446 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5447 return QualType();
5448 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005449
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005450 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5451 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5452 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5453 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005454 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005455 return QualType();
5456 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005457
5458 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5459 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5460 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5461 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5462 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005463 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5464 << rex->getSourceRange()
5465 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005466 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005467
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005468 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5469 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5470 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5471 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5472 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5473 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5474 return QualType();
5475 }
5476 } else {
5477 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5478 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5479 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5480 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5481 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5482 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5483 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5484 return QualType();
5485 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005486 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005487
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005488 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5489 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5490 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5491 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5492 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005493 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005494 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005495
5496 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005497 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5498 }
5499 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005500
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005501 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005502}
5503
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005504static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5505 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5506 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5507 return false;
5508}
5509
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005510// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005511QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005512 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005513 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005514 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5515 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005516 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005517
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005518 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5519 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5520 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5521 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5522 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5523 }
5524
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005525 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5526 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5527 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5528
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005529 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5530 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005531 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5532 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5533 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5534 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5535 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005536 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005537 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005538 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005539
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005540 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005541
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005542 // Sanity-check shift operands
5543 llvm::APSInt Right;
5544 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005545 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5546 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005547 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005548 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5549 else {
5550 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5551 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5552 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5553 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5554 }
5555 }
5556
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005557 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005558 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005559}
5560
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005561static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5562 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5563 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5564 return true;
5565 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5566 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5567 }
5568 return false;
5569}
5570
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005571// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005572QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005573 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005574 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005575
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005576 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005577 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005578 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005579
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005580 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5581 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005582
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005583 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenek853734e2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005584 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5585 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5586 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005587 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5588 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5589 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005590 //
5591 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5592 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5593 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5594 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5595 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5596 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005597 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5598 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005599 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005600 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenek853734e2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005601 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005602 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005603 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5604 << 0 // self-
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005605 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5606 || Opc == BO_LE
5607 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005608 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5609 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5610 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5611 // what is it always going to eval to?
5612 char always_evals_to;
5613 switch(Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005614 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005615 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5616 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005617 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005618 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5619 break;
5620 default:
5621 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5622 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5623 break;
5624 }
5625 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5626 << 1 // array
5627 << always_evals_to);
5628 }
5629 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005630 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005631
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005632 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5633 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5634 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5635 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005636
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005637 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5638 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005639 Expr *literalString = 0;
5640 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005641 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005642 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005643 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005644 literalString = lex;
5645 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005646 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5647 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005648 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005649 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005650 literalString = rex;
5651 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5652 }
5653
5654 if (literalString) {
5655 std::string resultComparison;
5656 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005657 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5658 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5659 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5660 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5661 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5662 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005663 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5664 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005665
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005666 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5667 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5668 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005669 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005670 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005671 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005672
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005673 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5674 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5675 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5676 else {
5677 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5678 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5679 }
5680
5681 lType = lex->getType();
5682 rType = rex->getType();
5683
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005684 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005685 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005686
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005687 if (isRelational) {
5688 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005689 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005690 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005691 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005692 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005693 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005694
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005695 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005696 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005697 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005698
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005699 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005700 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005701 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005702 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005703
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005704 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5705 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005706 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005707 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005708 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005709 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005710 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005711
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005712 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005713 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5714 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005715 if (!isRelational &&
5716 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5717 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5718 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005719 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5720 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005721 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5722 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005723 Diag(Loc,
5724 isSFINAEContext()?
5725 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5726 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005727 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005728
5729 if (isSFINAEContext())
5730 return QualType();
5731
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005732 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005733 return ResultTy;
5734 }
5735 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005736 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5737 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5738 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5739 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5740 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5741 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005742 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005743 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005744 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005745 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005746 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005747 if (T.isNull()) {
5748 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5749 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5750 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005751 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005752 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005753 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005754 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005755 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005756 }
5757
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005758 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5759 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005760 return ResultTy;
5761 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005762 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5763 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5764 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5765 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5766 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5767 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5768 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5769 }
5770 } else if (!isRelational &&
5771 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5772 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5773 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5774 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5775 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5776 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5777 }
5778 } else {
5779 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005780 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005781 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005782 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005783 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005784 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005785 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005786 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005787
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005788 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005789 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005790 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005791 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005792 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5793 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005794 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5795 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005796 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5797 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005798 return ResultTy;
5799 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005800 if (LHSIsNull &&
5801 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5802 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005803 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5804 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005805 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5806 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005807 return ResultTy;
5808 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005809
5810 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005811 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005812 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5813 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005814 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5815 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5816 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5817 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5818 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5819 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5820 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5821 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005822 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005823 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005824 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005825 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005826 if (T.isNull()) {
5827 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005828 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005829 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005830 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005831 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005832 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005833 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005834 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005835 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005836
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005837 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5838 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005839 return ResultTy;
5840 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005841
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005842 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005843 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5844 return ResultTy;
5845 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005846
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005847 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005848 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005849 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5850 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005851
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005852 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005853 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005854 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005855 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005856 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005857 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005858 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005859 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005860 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005861 if (!isRelational
5862 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5863 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005864 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005865 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005866 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005867 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005868 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5869 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5870 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005871 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005872 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005873 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005874 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005875
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005876 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005877 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005878 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5879 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005880 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005881 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005882 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005883 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005884
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005885 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5886 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005887 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005888 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005889 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005890 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005891 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005892 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005893 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005894 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005895 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5896 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005897 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005898 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005899 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005900 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005901 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5902 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005903 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005904 bool isError = false;
5905 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5906 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5907 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005908 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005909 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005910 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005911 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5912 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5913 isError = true;
5914 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005915 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005916
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005917 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005918 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005919 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005920 if (isError)
5921 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005922 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005923
5924 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005925 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005926 else
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005927 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005928 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005929 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005930
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005931 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005932 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5933 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005934 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005935 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005936 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005937 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5938 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005939 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005940 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005941 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005942 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005943}
5944
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005945/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005946/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005947/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5948/// types.
5949QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005950 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005951 bool isRelational) {
5952 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5953 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005954 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005955 if (vType.isNull())
5956 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005957
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005958 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5959 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005960
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005961 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5962 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5963 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005964 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005965 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5966 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5967 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005968 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5969 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5970 << 0 // self-
5971 << 2 // "a constant"
5972 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005973 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005974
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005975 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005976 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5977 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005978 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005979 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005980
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005981 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5982 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5983 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005984 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005985 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005986
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005987 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005988 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005989 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005990 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005991 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005992 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5993
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005994 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005995 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005996 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5997}
5998
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005999inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006000 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006001 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
6002 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
6003 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6004 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6005
6006 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6007 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00006008
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006009 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006010
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00006011 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
6012 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006013 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006014 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006015}
6016
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006017inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006018 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
6019
6020 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
6021 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
6022 // is a constant.
6023 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00006024 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00006025 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006026 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
6027 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
6028 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
6029 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
6030 Expr::EvalResult Result;
6031 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
6032 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
6033 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
6034 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006035 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
6036 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006037 }
6038 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006039
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006040 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6041 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6042 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006043
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006044 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
6045 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006046
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006047 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00006048 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006049
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006050 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
6051 // non-overloadable operands.
6052
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006053 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
6054 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006055 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
6056 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
6057 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006058 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006059
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006060 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
6061 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
6062 // The result is a bool.
6063 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006064}
6065
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006066/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
6067/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
6068/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
6069///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006070static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006071 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6072 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
6073 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00006074 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->isSuperReceiver() ?
6075 PropExpr->getSuperType() :
6076 PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
6077
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006078 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006079 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6080 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6081 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6082 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006083 }
6084 }
6085 return false;
6086}
6087
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006088/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6089/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6090static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006091 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006092 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006093 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006094 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6095 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006096 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6097 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006098
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006099 unsigned Diag = 0;
6100 bool NeedType = false;
6101 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006102 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006103 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006104 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6105 NeedType = true;
6106 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006107 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006108 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6109 NeedType = true;
6110 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006111 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006112 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6113 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006114 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6115 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006116 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006117 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6118 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006119 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6120 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006121 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6122 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006123 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006124 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006125 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006126 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006127 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6128 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006129 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006130 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6131 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006132 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6133 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6134 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006135 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6136 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6137 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006138 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6139 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6140 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006141 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006142
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006143 SourceRange Assign;
6144 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6145 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006146 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006147 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006148 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006149 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006150 return true;
6151}
6152
6153
6154
6155// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006156QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6157 SourceLocation Loc,
6158 QualType CompoundType) {
6159 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6160 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006161 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006162
6163 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6164 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006165 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006166 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006167 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006168 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006169 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006170 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006171 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6172 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6173 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006174 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006175 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006176 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006177 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006178
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006179 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6180 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6181 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006182 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006183 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6184 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6185 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006186 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6187 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006188 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006189 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006190 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6191 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6192 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006193 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6194 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006195 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006196 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006197 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006198 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006199 }
6200 } else {
6201 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006202 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006203 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006204
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006205 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006206 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006207 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006208
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006209
6210 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6211 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6212 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6213 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6214 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6215 // check.
6216 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006217 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006218 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6219 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6220 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6221 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6222 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6223 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6224 }
6225
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006226 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6227 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006228 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006229 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6230 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006231 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006232 // operand.
John McCall01cbf2d2010-10-12 02:19:57 +00006233 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6234 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006235}
6236
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006237// C99 6.5.17
6238QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006239 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6240
John McCall73d36182010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006241 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
6242 // operands, but not unary promotions.
6243 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6244 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6245 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS);
6246 if (!LHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6247 RequireCompleteType(Loc, LHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006248
John McCall73d36182010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006249 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
6250 if (!RHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6251 RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
6252 }
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006253
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006254 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006255}
6256
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006257/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6258/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006259QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006260 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006261 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6262 return Context.DependentTy;
6263
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006264 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6265 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006266
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006267 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6268 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6269 if (!isInc) {
6270 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6271 return QualType();
6272 }
6273 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6274 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6275 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006276 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006277 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6278 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006279
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006280 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006281 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006282 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6283 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6284 << Op->getSourceRange();
6285 return QualType();
6286 }
6287
6288 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006289 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006290 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006291 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6292 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6293 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6294 return QualType();
6295 }
6296
6297 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006298 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006299 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006300 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006301 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006302 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006303 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006304 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006305 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006306 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6307 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6308 return QualType();
6309 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006310 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006311 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6312 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006313 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006314 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6315 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6316 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6317 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc, isInc, isPrefix);
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006318 } else {
6319 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006320 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006321 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006322 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006323 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006324 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006325 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006326 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006327 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6328 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6329 // operand.
6330 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6331 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006332}
6333
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006334void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6335 bool copyInit = false;
6336 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6337 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6338 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6339 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6340 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6341 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6342 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6343 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6344 }
6345 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6346 }
6347 else
6348 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6349 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6350 if (copyInit) {
6351 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006352 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006353 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6354 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6355 Owned(Arg));
6356 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006357 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006358 }
6359}
6360
6361
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006362/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006363/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006364/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6365/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6366/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6367/// - &(x) => x
6368/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6369/// - &s.xx => s
6370/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6371/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6372/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6373/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006374static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006375 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006376 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006377 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006378 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006379 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6380 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6381 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006382 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006383 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006384 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006385 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006386 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006387 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6388 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006389 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6390 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6391 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6392 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6393 }
6394 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006395 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006396 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6397 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006398
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006399 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006400 case UO_Real:
6401 case UO_Imag:
6402 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006403 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6404 default:
6405 return 0;
6406 }
6407 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006408 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006409 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006410 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006411 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6412 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006413 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006414 default:
6415 return 0;
6416 }
6417}
6418
6419/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006420/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006421/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006422/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006423/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006424/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006425/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006426QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6427 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006428 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006429 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6430 return Context.OverloadTy;
6431
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006432 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp, OpLoc);
6433 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6434 OrigOp = PR.take();
6435
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006436 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6437 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006438
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006439 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6440 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6441 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006442 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006443 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6444 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6445 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6446 }
6447 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6448 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6449 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006450 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006451 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006452
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006453 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006454 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6455 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6456 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6457 if (isSFINAEContext())
6458 return QualType();
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006459 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006460 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006461 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6462 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6463 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6464
6465 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6466 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6467 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6468 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6469 return QualType();
6470 }
6471 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6472 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6473
6474 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6475 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6476 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6477 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6478
6479 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6480 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6481 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6482 << op->getSourceRange();
6483 }
6484
6485 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6486 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6487 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006488 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006489 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006490 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006491 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006492 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6493 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006494 return QualType();
6495 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006496 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006497 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6498 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6499 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006500 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006501 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006502 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006503 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006504 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006505 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006506 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6507 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6508 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6509 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6510 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006511 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6512 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006513 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6514 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006515 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006516 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006517 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6518 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006519 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6520 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCall8e7d6562010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006521 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006522 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006523 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6524 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006525 return QualType();
6526 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006527 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006528 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006529 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006530 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006531 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6532 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006533 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006534 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006535 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6536 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006537 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006538 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6539 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6540 return QualType();
6541 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006542
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006543 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6544 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006545 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006546 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006547 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006548 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006549 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006550
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006551 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6552 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6553 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6554 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6555 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6556 }
6557
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006558 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006559 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6560 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006561 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006562}
6563
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006564/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006565QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006566 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6567 return Context.DependentTy;
6568
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006569 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006570 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6571 QualType Result;
6572
6573 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6574 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6575 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6576 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6577 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6578 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6579 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6580 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6581 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006582 else {
6583 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6584 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6585 if (PR.take() != Op) return CheckIndirectionOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc);
6586 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006587
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006588 if (Result.isNull()) {
6589 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6590 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6591 return QualType();
6592 }
6593
6594 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006595}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006596
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006597static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006598 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006599 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006600 switch (Kind) {
6601 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006602 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6603 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6604 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6605 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6606 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6607 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6608 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6609 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6610 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6611 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6612 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6613 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6614 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6615 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6616 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6617 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6618 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6619 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6620 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6621 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6622 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6623 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6624 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6625 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6626 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6627 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6628 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6629 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6630 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6631 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6632 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6633 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006634 }
6635 return Opc;
6636}
6637
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006638static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006639 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006640 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006641 switch (Kind) {
6642 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006643 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6644 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6645 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6646 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6647 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6648 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6649 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6650 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6651 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6652 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6653 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006654 }
6655 return Opc;
6656}
6657
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006658/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6659/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6660/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006661ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006662 unsigned Op,
6663 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006664 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006665 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006666 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6667 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6668 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006669
6670 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006671 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006672 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6673 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006674 case BO_PtrMemD:
6675 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006676 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006677 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006678 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006679 case BO_Mul:
6680 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006681 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006682 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006683 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006684 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006685 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6686 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006687 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006688 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6689 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006690 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006691 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6692 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006693 case BO_Shl:
6694 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006695 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6696 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006697 case BO_LE:
6698 case BO_LT:
6699 case BO_GE:
6700 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006701 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006702 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006703 case BO_EQ:
6704 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006705 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006706 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006707 case BO_And:
6708 case BO_Xor:
6709 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006710 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6711 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006712 case BO_LAnd:
6713 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006714 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006715 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006716 case BO_MulAssign:
6717 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006718 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006719 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006720 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6721 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6722 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006723 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006724 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006725 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6726 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6727 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6728 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006729 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006730 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006731 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6732 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6733 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006734 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006735 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006736 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6737 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6738 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006739 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006740 case BO_ShlAssign:
6741 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006742 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6743 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6744 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6745 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006746 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006747 case BO_AndAssign:
6748 case BO_XorAssign:
6749 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006750 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6751 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6752 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6753 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006754 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006755 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006756 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6757 break;
6758 }
6759 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006760 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006761 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006762 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006763 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6764 << ResultTy;
6765 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006766 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006767 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6768 else
6769 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006770 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6771 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006772}
6773
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006774/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6775/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006776static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6777 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006778 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6779 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6780 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006781 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006782 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6783
6784 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6785 return;
6786
6787 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6788 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6789 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006790 return;
6791 }
6792
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006793 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6794 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006795 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006796
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006797 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006798 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006799
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006800 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6801 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6802 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6803 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006804 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006805 return;
6806 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006807
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006808 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006809 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6810 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006811}
6812
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006813/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6814/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6815/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6816/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006817static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006818 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006819 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6820 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6821 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6822 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006823 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006824 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006825 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6826
6827 // Subs are not binary operators.
6828 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6829 return;
6830
6831 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6832 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006833 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6834 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006835 return;
6836
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006837 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006838 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006839 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006840 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6841 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006842 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006843 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006844 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6845 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6846 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6847 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006848 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006849 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006850 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006851 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6852 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006853 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006854 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006855 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6856 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6857 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6858 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006859}
6860
6861/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6862/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6863/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006864static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006865 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006866 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006867 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6868}
6869
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006870// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006871ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006872 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6873 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6874 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006875 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6876 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006877
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006878 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6879 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6880
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006881 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6882}
6883
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006884ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006885 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6886 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006887 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006888 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6889 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianaaf44b22010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006890 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006891 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006892 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6893 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6894 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6895 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6896 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006897 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006898 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006899 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6900 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6901 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006902
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006903 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6904 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006905 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006906 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006907
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006908 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006909 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006910}
6911
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006912ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006913 unsigned OpcIn,
6914 Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006915 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006916
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006917 QualType resultType;
6918 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006919 case UO_PreInc:
6920 case UO_PreDec:
6921 case UO_PostInc:
6922 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006923 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006924 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6925 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6926 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6927 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006928 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006929 case UO_AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006930 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006931 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006932 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006933 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006934 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006935 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006936 case UO_Plus:
6937 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006938 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6939 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006940 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6941 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006942 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6943 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006944 break;
6945 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6946 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6947 break;
6948 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006949 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006950 resultType->isPointerType())
6951 break;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006952 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6953 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6954 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6955 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6956 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006957
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006958 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6959 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006960 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006961 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6962 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006963 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6964 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006965 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6966 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6967 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006968 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006969 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006970 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6971 break;
6972 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6973 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6974 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6975 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6976 } else {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006977 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6978 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006979 }
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006980 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006981 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006982 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006983 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006984 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006985 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6986 break;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006987 if (resultType->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6988 // ok, fallthrough
6989 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6990 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6991 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6992 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6993 } else {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006994 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6995 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006996 }
Douglas Gregordb8c6fd2010-09-20 17:13:33 +00006997
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006998 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006999 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
7000 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00007001 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007002 case UO_Real:
7003 case UO_Imag:
7004 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00007005 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007006 case UO_Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00007007 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00007008 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00007009 }
7010 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007011 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007012
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007013 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00007014}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007015
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007016ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007017 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
7018 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00007019 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman8ed2bac2010-09-05 23:15:52 +00007020 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007021 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
7022 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
7023 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
7024 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007025 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007026 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007027 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
7028 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
7029 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007030
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007031 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007032 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007033
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007034 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007035}
7036
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007037// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007038ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007039 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
7040 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007041}
7042
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00007043/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007044ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007045 SourceLocation LabLoc,
7046 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007047 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007048 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007049
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00007050 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
7051 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00007052 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007053 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007054
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007055 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007056 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007057 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
7058 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007059}
7060
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007061ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007062Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007063 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007064 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
7065 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
7066
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00007067 bool isFileScope
7068 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00007069 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007070 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00007071
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007072 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
7073 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
7074 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007075
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007076 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
7077 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
7078 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian56143ae2010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007079 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007080 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
7081 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
Fariborz Jahanian56143ae2010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007082 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = 0;
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007083 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
Fariborz Jahanian56143ae2010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007084 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) {
7085 LastLabelStmt = Label;
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007086 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Fariborz Jahanian56143ae2010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007087 }
7088 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandd6907b2010-10-27 20:44:00 +00007089 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LastExpr);
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007090 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian56143ae2010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007091 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
7092 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
7093 InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc,
7094 Ty,
7095 false),
7096 SourceLocation(),
7097 Owned(LastExpr));
7098 if (Res.isInvalid())
7099 return ExprError();
7100 if ((LastExpr = Res.takeAs<Expr>())) {
7101 if (!LastLabelStmt)
7102 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr);
7103 else
7104 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr);
7105 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
7106 }
7107 }
7108 }
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007109 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007110
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007111 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
7112 // expressions are not lvalues.
Fariborz Jahanian56143ae2010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007113 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc);
7114 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
7115 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
7116 return Owned(ResStmtExpr);
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007117}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007118
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007119ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007120 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7121 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7122 unsigned NumComponents,
7123 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007124 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007125 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00007126 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007127
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007128 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7129 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7130 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007131 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007132 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7133 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
7134
7135 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7136 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
7137 if (!Dependent
7138 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
7139 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
7140 << TypeRange))
7141 return ExprError();
7142
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007143 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7144 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007145 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7146 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007147 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007148 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7149 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007150
7151 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7152 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7153 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7154 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7155 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7156 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7157 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7158 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7159 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7160 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7161 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7162 if(!AT)
7163 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7164 << CurrentType);
7165 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7166 } else
7167 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7168
7169 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7170 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7171 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7172 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7173 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7174 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7175 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7176 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7177
7178 // Record this array index.
7179 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7180 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7181 continue;
7182 }
7183
7184 // Offset of a field.
7185 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7186 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7187 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7188 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7189 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7190 continue;
7191 }
7192
7193 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7194 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7195 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7196 return ExprError();
7197
7198 // Look for the designated field.
7199 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7200 if (!RC)
7201 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7202 << CurrentType);
7203 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7204
7205 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7206 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7207 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7208 // (clause 9).
7209 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7210 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7211 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7212 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7213 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7214 << CurrentType))
7215 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7216 }
7217
7218 // Look for the field.
7219 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7220 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7221 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7222 if (!MemberDecl)
7223 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7224 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7225 OC.LocEnd));
7226
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007227 // C99 7.17p3:
7228 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7229 //
7230 // We diagnose this as an error.
7231 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7232 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7233 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7234 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7235 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7236 return ExprError();
7237 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007238
7239 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7240 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7241 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7242 do {
7243 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7244 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7245 }
7246
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007247 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7248 // the base class indirections.
7249 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7250 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007251 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007252 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7253 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7254 B != BEnd; ++B)
7255 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7256 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007257
7258 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007259 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7260 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7261 unsigned n = Path.size();
7262 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7263 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7264 } else {
7265 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7266 }
7267 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7268 }
7269
7270 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7271 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7272 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7273}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007274
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007275ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007276 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7277 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7278 ParsedType argty,
7279 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7280 unsigned NumComponents,
7281 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7282
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007283 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7284 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7285 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7286 return ExprError();
7287
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007288 if (!ArgTInfo)
7289 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7290
7291 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7292 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007293}
7294
7295
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007296ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007297 ParsedType arg1, ParsedType arg2,
7298 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007299 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7300 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7301 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7302 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007303
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007304 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007305
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007306 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7307}
7308
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007309ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007310Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7311 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7312 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7313 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007314 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7315 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7316 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7317 return ExprError();
7318 }
7319
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007320 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007321 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007322}
7323
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007324
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007325ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007326 Expr *CondExpr,
7327 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7328 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007329 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7330
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007331 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007332 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007333 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007334 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007335 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007336 } else {
7337 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7338 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7339 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7340 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007341 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7342 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7343 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007344
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007345 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7346 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007347 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7348 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007349 }
7350
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007351 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007352 resType, RPLoc,
7353 resType->isDependentType(),
7354 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007355}
7356
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007357//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7358// Clang Extensions.
7359//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7360
7361/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007362void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007363 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7364 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7365 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007366 if (BlockScope)
7367 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7368 else
7369 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007370}
7371
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007372void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007373 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007374 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007375
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007376 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007377 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007378 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007379
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007380 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007381 QualType RetTy;
7382 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007383 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007384 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007385 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007386 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7387 } else {
7388 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007389 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007390 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007391
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007392 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007393
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007394 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7395 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7396 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007397 return;
7398 }
7399
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007400 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7401 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7402 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7403 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7404 return;
7405 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007406
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007407 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007408 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7409 // ^ * { ... }
7410 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007411 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7412 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007413
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007414 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007415 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007416 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7417 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7418 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7419 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007420 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7421 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7422 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7423 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7424 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007425 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007426 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007427
7428 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7429 // ^ fntype { ... }
7430 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7431 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7432 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7433 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7434 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7435 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7436 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007437 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007438 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007439 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007440
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007441 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
Douglas Gregorb524d902010-11-01 18:37:59 +00007442 if (!Params.empty()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007443 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
Douglas Gregorb524d902010-11-01 18:37:59 +00007444 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7445 CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(),
7446 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false);
7447 }
7448
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007449 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007450 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007451
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007452 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007453 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7454 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7455 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7456 }
7457
7458 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7459 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007460 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007461 return;
7462
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007463 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7464 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7465
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007466 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007467 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7468 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7469
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007470 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007471 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7472 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7473 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7474
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007475 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007476 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007477 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007478}
7479
7480/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7481/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7482void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007483 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007484 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007485 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007486}
7487
7488/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7489/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007490ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007491 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007492 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7493 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7494 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007495
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007496 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007497
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007498 PopDeclContext();
7499
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007500 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007501 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7502 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007503
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007504 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007505 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007506
7507 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7508 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7509 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7510
7511 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7512 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7513
7514 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7515 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7516 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7517 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7518
7519 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7520 // preserve its sugar structure.
7521 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7522 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7523 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7524
7525 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7526 } else {
7527 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7528 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7529 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7530 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7531 FPT->isVariadic(),
7532 /*quals*/ 0,
7533 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7534 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7535 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7536 FPT->exception_begin(),
7537 Ext);
7538 }
7539
7540 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7541 } else {
7542 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7543 false, false, 0, 0,
7544 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7545 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007546
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007547 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7548 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007549 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007550
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007551 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007552 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007553 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007554
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007555 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007556
7557 bool Good = true;
7558 // Check goto/label use.
7559 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7560 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7561 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7562
7563 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7564 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007565 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7566 if (!L->isUsed())
7567 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007568 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007569 }
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007570
7571 // Emit error.
7572 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7573 Good = false;
7574 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007575 if (!Good) {
7576 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007577 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007578 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007579
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007580 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7581 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7582
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007583 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007584 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7585 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007586 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007587
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007588 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007589 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007590}
7591
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007592ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007593 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007594 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007595 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7596 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007597 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007598}
7599
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007600ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007601 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007602 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007603 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007604
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007605 // Get the va_list type
7606 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007607 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7608 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7609 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7610 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007611 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007612 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7613 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7614 } else {
7615 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7616 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007617 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007618 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007619 return ExprError();
7620 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007621
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007622 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7623 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007624 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7625 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007626 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007627 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007628
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007629 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007630 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007631
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007632 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7633 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007634}
7635
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007636ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007637 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7638 // pointers on the target.
7639 QualType Ty;
7640 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7641 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7642 else
7643 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7644
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007645 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007646}
7647
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007648static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007649 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007650 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7651 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007652
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007653 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7654 if (!PT)
7655 return;
7656
7657 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7658 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7659 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7660 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7661 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7662 return;
7663 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007664
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007665 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7666 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7667 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7668 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007669
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007670 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007671}
7672
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007673bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7674 SourceLocation Loc,
7675 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007676 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7677 bool *Complained) {
7678 if (Complained)
7679 *Complained = false;
7680
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007681 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7682 bool isInvalid = false;
7683 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007684 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007685
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007686 switch (ConvTy) {
7687 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7688 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007689 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007690 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7691 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007692 case IntToPointer:
7693 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7694 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007695 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007696 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007697 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7698 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007699 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7700 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7701 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007702 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7703 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7704 break;
7705 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007706 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7707 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7708 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7709 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7710 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7711 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7712 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7713 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7714 // C++ semantics.
7715 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7716 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7717 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007718 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7719 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007720 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007721 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007722 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007723 case IntToBlockPointer:
7724 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7725 break;
7726 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007727 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007728 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007729 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007730 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007731 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7732 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7733 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007734 case IncompatibleVectors:
7735 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7736 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007737 case Incompatible:
7738 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7739 isInvalid = true;
7740 break;
7741 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007742
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007743 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7744 switch (Action) {
7745 case AA_Assigning:
7746 case AA_Initializing:
7747 // The destination type comes first.
7748 FirstType = DstType;
7749 SecondType = SrcType;
7750 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007751
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007752 case AA_Returning:
7753 case AA_Passing:
7754 case AA_Converting:
7755 case AA_Sending:
7756 case AA_Casting:
7757 // The source type comes first.
7758 FirstType = SrcType;
7759 SecondType = DstType;
7760 break;
7761 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007762
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007763 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007764 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007765 if (Complained)
7766 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007767 return isInvalid;
7768}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007769
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007770bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007771 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7772 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7773 if (Result)
7774 *Result = ICEResult;
7775 return false;
7776 }
7777
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007778 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7779
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007780 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007781 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7782 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7783
7784 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7785 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7786 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7787 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7788 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7789 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7790 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007791
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007792 return true;
7793 }
7794
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007795 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7796 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007797
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007798 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7799 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7800 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007801
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007802 if (Result)
7803 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7804 return false;
7805}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007806
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007807void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007808Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007809 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7810 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007811}
7812
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007813void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007814Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7815 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7816 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7817 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007818
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007819 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7820 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7821 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7822 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7823 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007824 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007825 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7826 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7827 I != IEnd; ++I)
7828 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7829 }
7830
7831 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7832 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7833 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7834 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7835 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7836 I != IEnd; ++I)
7837 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7838 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007839 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007840
7841 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7842 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7843 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7844 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007845 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007846 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7847 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7848 ExprTemporaries.end());
7849
7850 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7851 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007852}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007853
7854/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7855///
7856/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7857/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7858/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7859/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7860///
7861/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7862///
7863/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7864void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7865 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007866
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007867 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007868 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007869
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007870 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7871 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7872 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7873 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007874 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007875 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Anders Carlsson73067a02010-10-22 23:37:08 +00007876 D->setUsed();
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007877 return;
7878 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007879
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007880 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7881 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007882
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007883 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7884 // an instantiation.
7885 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7886 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007887
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007888 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007889 case Unevaluated:
7890 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7891 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007892
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007893 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7894 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7895 // "used"; handle this below.
7896 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007897
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007898 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7899 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7900 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7901 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007902 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007903 return;
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007904
7905 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7906 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7907 // containing expression is used.
7908 return;
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007909 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007910
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007911 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007912 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007913 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007914 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruthc9262402010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007915 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7916 return;
7917 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7918 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007919 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007920 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007921 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007922 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7923 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007924
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007925 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007926 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007927 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007928 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007929 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7930 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007931 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7932 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7933 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007934 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007935 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007936 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7937 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007938 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007939 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007940 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007941 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007942 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007943 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7944 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7945 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7946 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7947 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007948 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007949 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007950 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007951 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007952 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7953 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7954 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007955 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007956 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007957 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7958 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007959
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007960 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7961 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7962 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7963 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7964 Loc));
7965 else
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007966 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007967 }
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007968 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7969 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7970 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greif34ecff22010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007971 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007972 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7973 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007974
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007975 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidisdfffabd2010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007976
7977 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7978 if (CurContext != Function)
7979 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007980
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007981 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007982 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007983
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007984 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007985 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007986 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007987 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7988 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7989 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7990 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7991 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7992 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007993 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007994 }
7995 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007996
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007997 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007998
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007999 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008000 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00008001 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008002}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008003
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008004namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008005 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008006 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008007 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008008 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
8009 Sema &S;
8010 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008011
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008012 public:
8013 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008014
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008015 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008016
8017 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
8018 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008019 };
8020}
8021
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008022bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
8023 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008024 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
8025 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
8026 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008027
8028 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008029}
8030
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008031bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008032 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
8033 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
8034 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008035 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
8036 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008037 }
8038
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00008039 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008040}
8041
8042void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
8043 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008044 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008045}
8046
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008047namespace {
8048 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
8049 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8050 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
8051 Sema &S;
8052
8053 public:
8054 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
8055
8056 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
8057
8058 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
8059 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8060 }
8061
8062 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
8063 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008064 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008065 }
8066
8067 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
8068 if (E->getConstructor())
8069 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
8070 if (E->getOperatorNew())
8071 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
8072 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8073 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008074 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008075 }
8076
8077 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
8078 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8079 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00008080 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
8081 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8082 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
8083 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
8084 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
8085 }
8086
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008087 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008088 }
8089
8090 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
8091 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008092 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008093 }
8094
8095 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
8096 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8097 }
Douglas Gregorf0873f42010-10-19 17:17:35 +00008098
8099 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
8100 Visit(E->getExpr());
8101 }
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008102 };
8103}
8104
8105/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
8106/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8107void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
8108 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
8109}
8110
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008111/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
8112/// of the program being compiled.
8113///
8114/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008115/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008116/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
8117/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
8118/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
8119/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008120/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008121/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008122///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008123/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
8124/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
8125/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
8126/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008127bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008128 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
8129 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
8130 case Unevaluated:
8131 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
8132 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008133
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008134 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008135 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008136 Diag(Loc, PD);
8137 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008138
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008139 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8140 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
8141 break;
8142 }
8143
8144 return false;
8145}
8146
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008147bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8148 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8149 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8150 return false;
8151
8152 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8153 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8154 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8155 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008156
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008157 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008158 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008159 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8160 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008161 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008162 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8163 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8164 return true;
8165
8166 return false;
8167}
8168
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008169// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8170// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8171void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8172 SourceLocation Loc;
8173
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008174 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8175
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008176 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8177 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008178 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008179 return;
8180
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008181 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8182 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8183 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8184 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8185
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008186 // self = [<foo> init...]
8187 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8188 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8189 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8190
8191 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8192 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8193 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8194 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8195 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008196
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008197 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8198 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8199 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8200 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8201 return;
8202
8203 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8204 } else {
8205 // Not an assignment.
8206 return;
8207 }
8208
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008209 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008210 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008211
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008212 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008213 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008214 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008215 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8216 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8217 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008218}
8219
8220bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8221 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8222
8223 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca766292010-11-01 18:49:26 +00008224 if (E->isBoundMemberFunction(Context))
8225 return Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_invalid_use_of_bound_member_func)
8226 << E->getSourceRange();
8227
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008228 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008229
8230 QualType T = E->getType();
8231
8232 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8233 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8234 return true;
8235 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8236 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8237 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8238 return true;
8239 }
8240 }
8241
8242 return false;
8243}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008244
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008245ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8246 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008247 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008248 return ExprError();
8249
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008250 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008251 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008252
8253 return Owned(Sub);
8254}
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008255
8256/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
8257/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
8258ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8259 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8260 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
8261
8262 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
8263 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
8264 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
8265 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
8266 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
8267 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
8268 Specialization->getAccess());
8269 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
8270 if (!E) return ExprError();
8271 return Owned(E);
8272 }
8273
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008274 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ovl_unresolvable) << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008275 return ExprError();
8276 }
8277
8278 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
8279 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
8280
8281 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
8282 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
8283 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
8284 return ExprError();
8285}